Flash handling for STM32F76x/77x and F446 added
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose.
2519
2520 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2521 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2522 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2523 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2524
2525 @itemize @minus
2526 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2527 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2528 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2529 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2530 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2531 switching data and direction as necessary
2532 @end itemize
2533
2534 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2535 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2538 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2539 default values are used.
2540 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2541 @example
2542 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2543 @end example
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2547 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2548 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2549 during device selection.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2553 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2554 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2555 is connected to the host.
2556 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2557 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2558 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2562 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2563 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2564 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2565 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2566 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2567
2568 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2572 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2573 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2577 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2578 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2579 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2580 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2581 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2582 and initially asserted reset signals.
2583 @end deffn
2584
2585 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2586 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2587 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2588 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2589 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2590 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2591 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2592 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2593 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2594
2595 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2596 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2597 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2598 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2599 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2600 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2601
2602 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2603 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2604 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2605 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2606 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2607 are always driven by the FTDI.
2608
2609 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2610 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2611 @var{name}.
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2615 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item @option{0}, drive low
2618 @item @option{1}, drive high
2619 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2620 @end itemize
2621 @end deffn
2622
2623 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2624 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2625
2626 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2627 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2628 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2629 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2632 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2633 @end itemize
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2637 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2638
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2642 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2643 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2644 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2645
2646 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2647 processors which are being simulated.
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2650 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2651 sockets instead of TCP.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2655 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2656 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2660 something like:
2661
2662 @example
2663 interface remote_bitbang
2664 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2665 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2666 @end example
2667
2668 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2669 named mysocket:
2670
2671 @example
2672 interface remote_bitbang
2673 remote_bitbang_port 0
2674 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2675 @end example
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2679 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2680 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2681 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2684 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2685 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2686 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2687 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2691 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2692 default values are used.
2693 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2694 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2695 @example
2696 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2697 @end example
2698 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2699 @example
2700 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2701 @end example
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2705 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2706 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2707 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2708 target board.
2709
2710 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2711 @example
2712 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2713 reset_config srst_only
2714 @end example
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2718 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2719 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2720 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2721 @end deffn
2722
2723 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2724 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2725 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @end deffn
2729
2730 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2731 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2732 This has one driver-specific command:
2733
2734 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2735 Display either the address of the I/O port
2736 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2737 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2738 This is a write-once setting.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @end deffn
2741
2742 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2743 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2744 transports.
2745
2746 @quotation Compatibility Note
2747 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2748 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2749 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2750 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2751 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2752 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2753 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2754 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2755 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2756 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2757 @end quotation
2758
2759 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2760 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2761 states.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2764 Display free device internal memory.
2765 @end deffn
2766 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2767 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2768 command version.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2771 Display the device configuration.
2772 @end deffn
2773 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2774 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2775 power state.
2776 @end deffn
2777 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2778 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2781 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2782 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2783 IP configuration.
2784 @end deffn
2785 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2786 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2787 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2788 @end deffn
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2790 Reset the current configuration.
2791 @end deffn
2792 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2793 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2794 @end deffn
2795 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2796 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2797 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2798 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2799 instead.
2800
2801 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2804 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2805 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2806
2807 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2812 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2813 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2814 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2815 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2816
2817 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2818 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2819 This is a write-once setting.
2820 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2821
2822 @itemize @minus
2823 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2824 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2825 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2826 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2827 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2828 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2829 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2830 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2831 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2832 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2833 some versions of
2834 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2835 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2836 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2837 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2838 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2839 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2840 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2841 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2842 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2843 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2844 @end itemize
2845 @end deffn
2846
2847 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2848 Display either the address of the I/O port
2849 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2850 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2851 This is a write-once setting.
2852
2853 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2854 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2855 you may encounter a problem.
2856 @end deffn
2857
2858 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2859 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2860 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2861 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2862 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2863 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2864
2865 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2866 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2867 @quotation Tip
2868 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2869 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2870 @example
2871 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2872 > adapter_khz 500
2873 @end example
2874 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2875 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2876 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2877 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2878 large set of samples.
2879 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2880 @example
2881 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2882 @end example
2883 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2884 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2885
2886 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2887 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2888 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2889 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2890 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2891 @end quotation
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2895 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2896 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2900 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2901
2902 @example
2903 interface parport
2904 parport_port 0x278
2905 parport_cable wiggler
2906 @end example
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2910 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2912 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2913 @end deffn
2914 @end deffn
2915
2916 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2917 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2921 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2922 @end deffn
2923
2924 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2925 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2926
2927 @quotation Note
2928 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2929 which are not currently documented here.
2930 @end quotation
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @anchor{hla_interface}
2934 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2935 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2936 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2937 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2938
2939 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2940 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2941 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2942 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2943 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2944
2945 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2946 Currently Not Supported.
2947 @end deffn
2948
2949 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2950 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2951 @end deffn
2952
2953 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2954 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2955 @end deffn
2956
2957 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2958 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2962 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2963 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2964 @end deffn
2965 @end deffn
2966
2967 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2968 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2972 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2976 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2977 @end deffn
2978
2979 @quotation Note
2980 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2981 which are not currently documented here.
2982 @end quotation
2983
2984 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2985 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2986 No arguments: print status.
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2990 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2991 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2992
2993 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2994 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2995 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2996 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2997 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2998 configuration on exit.
2999
3000 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3001 pinout.
3002
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @section Transport Configuration
3006 @cindex Transport
3007 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3008 and the debug adapter you are using,
3009 several transports may be available to
3010 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3011 @deffn Command {transport list}
3012 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3013 version of OpenOCD.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3017 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3018
3019 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3020 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3021 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3022 adapter's driver).
3023
3024 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3025 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3026 supported by the debug adapter.
3027
3028 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3029 transport, if any.
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @subsection JTAG Transport
3033 @cindex JTAG
3034 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3035 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3036 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3037 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3038 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3039 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3040
3041 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3042 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3043 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3044 hla_jtag}.
3045
3046 @subsection SWD Transport
3047 @cindex SWD
3048 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3049 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3050 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3051 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3052 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3053 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3054 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3055
3056 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3057 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3058 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3059 hla_swd}.
3060
3061 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3062 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3063 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3064 expected to change.
3065 @end deffn
3066 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3067 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3068 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3069 No parameters: displays current settings.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @subsection SPI Transport
3073 @cindex SPI
3074 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3075 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3076 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3077 solution for flash programming.
3078
3079 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3080 @section JTAG Speed
3081 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3082 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3083 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3084 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3085 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3086 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3087 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3088 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3089 power management software that may be active.
3090
3091 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3092 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3093 target event handler.
3094 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3095 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3096 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3097 sets up those clocks).
3098 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3099 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3100 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3101 in the target config file.
3102 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3103 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3104 config file instead.
3105 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3106 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3107 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3108
3109 @example
3110 jtag_rclk 3000
3111 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3112 @end example
3113
3114 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3115 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3116 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3117 may not be the fastest solution.
3118
3119 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3120 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3121 which support adaptive clocking.
3122
3123 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3124 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3125 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3126 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3127 than the speed specified.
3128
3129 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3130 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3131 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3132 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3133
3134 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3135 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3136 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3137 JTAG clocking after setup.
3138 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3139 If the interface device can not
3140 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3144 @cindex adaptive clocking
3145 @cindex RTCK
3146 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3147 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3148 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3149 @example
3150 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3151 jtag_rclk 3000
3152 @end example
3153 @end defun
3154
3155 @node Reset Configuration
3156 @chapter Reset Configuration
3157 @cindex Reset Configuration
3158
3159 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3160 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3161 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3162 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3163 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3164 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3165 Please see the various board files for examples.
3166
3167 @quotation Note
3168 To maintainers and integrators:
3169 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3170 Normally the board configuration file
3171 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3172 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3173
3174 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3175 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3176 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3177 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3178 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3179 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3180 @end quotation
3181
3182 @section Types of Reset
3183
3184 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3185 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3186 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3187
3188 @itemize @bullet
3189 @item
3190 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3191 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3192 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3193 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3194 @item
3195 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3196 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3197 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3198 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3199 @item
3200 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3201 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3202 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3203 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3204 @item
3205 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3206 several other types of reset.
3207 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3208 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3209 There may be individual module resets.
3210 @end itemize
3211
3212 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3213 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3214 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3215 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3216 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3217 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3218 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3219 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3220 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3221
3222 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3223 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3224
3225 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3226 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3227 common issues are:
3228
3229 @itemize @bullet
3230
3231 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3232 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3233 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3234 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3235 when either of those signals is not connected.
3236 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3237 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3238 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3239 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3240
3241 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3242 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3243 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3244 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3245
3246 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3247 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3248 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3249 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3250 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3251 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3252 hardware debouncing.
3253 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3254 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3255
3256 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3257 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3258 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3259 to use push/pull output drivers.
3260 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3261 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3262 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3263 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3264
3265 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3266 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3267 issues (not limited to errata).
3268 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3269 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3270 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3271 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3272 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3273 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3274 @end itemize
3275
3276 There can also be other issues.
3277 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3278 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3279 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3280 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3281 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3282 Agreement (NDA).
3283
3284 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3285 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3286 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3287
3288 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3289 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3290
3291 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3292
3293 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3294 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3295 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3296 allowing it to be deasserted.
3297 @end deffn
3298
3299 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3300 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3301 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3302 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3303 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3304 @end deffn
3305
3306 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3307 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3308 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3309 allowing it to be deasserted.
3310 @end deffn
3311
3312 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3313 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3314 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3315 @end deffn
3316
3317 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3318 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3319 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3320 configuration scripts.
3321
3322 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3323 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3324 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3325 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3326 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3327 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3328 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3329 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3330
3331 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3332 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3333 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3334 -- may be specified at a time.
3335 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3336 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3337 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3338 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3339 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3340
3341 @itemize
3342 @item
3343 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3344 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3345 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3346 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3347 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3348
3349 @quotation Tip
3350 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3351 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3352 @end quotation
3353
3354 @item
3355 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3356 signal implementations.
3357 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3358 indicating everything behaves normally.
3359 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3360 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3361 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3362 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3363 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3364 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3365 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3366
3367 @item
3368 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3369 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3370 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3371 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3372 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3373 while SRST is asserted.
3374 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3375 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3376
3377 @item
3378 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3379 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3380 is required to use this option.
3381 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3382 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3383 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3384 be asserted before any target connection.
3385 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3386 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3387 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3388 @end itemize
3389
3390 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3391 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3392 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3393 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3394 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3395
3396 @itemize
3397 @item
3398 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3399 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3400 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3401 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3402
3403 @item
3404 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3405 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3406 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3407 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3408 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3409 @end itemize
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @section Custom Reset Handling
3413 @cindex events
3414
3415 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3416 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3417 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3418 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3419 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3420 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3421
3422 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3423 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3424 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3425 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3426 want to reset everything at once.
3427
3428 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3429 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3430 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3431 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3432 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3433 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3434 needs special attention.
3435
3436 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3437 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3438 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3439 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3440 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3441 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3442 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3443 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3444
3445 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3446 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3447 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3448 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3449 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3450
3451 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3452 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3453 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3454 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3455 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3456 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3457 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3458 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3459 or potentially some other value.
3460
3461 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3462 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3463 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3464 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3465 (or their associated targets)
3466 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3467
3468 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3469 they return.
3470 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3471 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3472 @end deffn
3473
3474 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3475 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3476 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3477 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3478 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3479 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3480 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3481 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3482 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3483 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3484 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3485 @end deffn
3486
3487 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3488 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3489 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3490 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3491 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3492 @end deffn
3493
3494
3495 @node TAP Declaration
3496 @chapter TAP Declaration
3497 @cindex TAP declaration
3498 @cindex TAP configuration
3499
3500 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3501 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3502
3503 @itemize @bullet
3504 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3505 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3506 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3507 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3508 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3509 start running that code.
3510 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3511 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3512 and missing connections.
3513 @end itemize
3514
3515 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3516 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3517 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3518 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3519 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3520
3521 @section Scan Chains
3522 @cindex scan chain
3523
3524 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3525 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3526 They also need to be added to
3527 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3528 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3529 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3530 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3531 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3532 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3533 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3534 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3535
3536 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3537 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3538 command, presented in the next chapter.
3539 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3540 debugging targets.)
3541 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3542
3543 @verbatim
3544 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3545 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3546 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3547 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3548 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3549 @end verbatim
3550
3551 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3552 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3553 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3554 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3555 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3556 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3557 until they are told to do so.
3558
3559 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3560 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3561 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3562 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3563
3564 @example
3565 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3566 @end example
3567
3568 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3569 by a given chip.
3570 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3571 and so forth.
3572 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3573 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3574 both inside a single chip and between them.
3575 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3576
3577 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3578 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3579 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3580 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3581 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3582 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3583 includes commands something like this:
3584
3585 @example
3586 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3587 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3588 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3589 @end example
3590
3591 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3592 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3593 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3594
3595 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3596 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3597 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3598 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3599 @example
3600 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3601 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3602 @}
3603 @end example
3604 @end deffn
3605
3606 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3607 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3608 and their status.
3609 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3610 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3611 but systems with a JTAG router can
3612 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3613 @end deffn
3614
3615 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3616 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3617
3618 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3619 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3620
3621 @section TAP Names
3622 @cindex dotted name
3623
3624 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3625 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3626 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3627 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3628 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3629 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3630 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3631 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3632
3633 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3634 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3635 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3636
3637 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3638
3639 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3640 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3641 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3642 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3643
3644 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3645 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3646 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3647 overridable.
3648
3649 @cindex TAP naming convention
3650 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3651 and should follow this convention:
3652
3653 @itemize @bullet
3654 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3655 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3656 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3657 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3658 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3659 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3660 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3661 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3662 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3663 with a single TAP;
3664 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3665 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3666 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3667 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3668 @end itemize
3669
3670 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3671
3672 @itemize @bullet
3673 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3674 @*The length in bits of the
3675 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3676 @end itemize
3677
3678 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3679
3680 @itemize @bullet
3681 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3682 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3683 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3684 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3685 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3686 (the TAP is linked in).
3687 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3688 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3689 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3690 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3691 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3692 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3693 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3694 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3695 values that were found but not included in the list.
3696
3697 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3698 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3699 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3700 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3701 hardware to find these values.
3702 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3703 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3704 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3705 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3706 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3707 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3708 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3709 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3710 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3711 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3712 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3713 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3714 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3715 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3716 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3717 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3718 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3719 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3720 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3721 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3722 @end itemize
3723 @end deffn
3724
3725 @section Other TAP commands
3726
3727 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3728 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3729 At this writing this TAP attribute
3730 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3731 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3732 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3733 See the next section for information about the available events.
3734
3735 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3736 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3737 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3738 @end deffn
3739
3740 @section TAP Events
3741 @cindex events
3742 @cindex TAP events
3743
3744 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3745 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3746 The other applies to debugger targets,
3747 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3748
3749 The TAP events currently defined are:
3750
3751 @itemize @bullet
3752 @item @b{post-reset}
3753 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3754 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3755 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3756 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3757 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3758
3759 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3760 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3761 of any particular target.
3762 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3763 @item @b{setup}
3764 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3765 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3766 @item @b{tap-disable}
3767 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3768 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3769 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3770 @item @b{tap-enable}
3771 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3772 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3773 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3774 @end itemize
3775
3776 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3777 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3778 contents to be accurate), you might:
3779
3780 @example
3781 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3782 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3783 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3784 @}
3785 @end example
3786
3787
3788 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3789 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3790 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3791 @cindex jrc
3792
3793 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3794 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3795 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3796 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3797 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3798
3799 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3800 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3801 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3802 be visible.
3803 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3804 ignores, such as:
3805
3806 @itemize
3807 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3808 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3809 TAPs receive new instructions.
3810 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3811 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3812 @end itemize
3813
3814 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3815 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3816 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3817 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3818
3819 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3820 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3821
3822 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3823 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3824 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3825 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3826 should define TAP event handlers using
3827 code that looks something like this:
3828
3829 @example
3830 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3831 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3832 @}
3833 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3834 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3835 @}
3836 @end example
3837
3838 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3839
3840 @example
3841 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3842 @end example
3843
3844 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3845 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3846 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3847 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3848
3849 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3850 If necessary, disables the tap
3851 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3852 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3853 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3854 and "0" if it is disabled.
3855 @end deffn
3856
3857 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3858 If necessary, enables the tap
3859 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3860 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3861 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3862 and "0" if it is disabled.
3863 @end deffn
3864
3865 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3866 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3867 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3868 and "0" if it is disabled.
3869
3870 @quotation Note
3871 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3872 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3873 @end quotation
3874 @end deffn
3875
3876 @anchor{autoprobing}
3877 @section Autoprobing
3878 @cindex autoprobe
3879 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3880
3881 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3882 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3883 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3884 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3885
3886 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3887 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3888 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3889 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3890 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3891 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3892 right when they come out of reset).
3893
3894 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3895
3896 @example
3897 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3898 reset_config trst_and_srst
3899 jtag_rclk 8
3900 @end example
3901
3902 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3903 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3904
3905 @enumerate
3906 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3907 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3908 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3909 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3910 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3911 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3912 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3913 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3914 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3915 that is discovered.
3916 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3917 register, it will report it.
3918 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3919 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3920 @end enumerate
3921
3922 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3923 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3924 that's a bit more complex:
3925
3926 @example
3927 clock speed 8 kHz
3928 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3929 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3930 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3931 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3932 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3933 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3934 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3935 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3936 @end example
3937
3938 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3939 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3940 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3941 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3942 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3943 and so forth.
3944
3945 @node CPU Configuration
3946 @chapter CPU Configuration
3947 @cindex GDB target
3948
3949 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3950 You can also access these targets without GDB
3951 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3952 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3953 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3954 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3955
3956 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3957 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3958
3959 @section Target List
3960 @cindex target, current
3961 @cindex target, list
3962
3963 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3964 where each member has a name.
3965 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3966 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3967 (plural!) command.
3968 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3969 look like with more than one:
3970 @verbatim
3971 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3972 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3973 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3974 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3975 @end verbatim
3976
3977 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3978 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3979 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3980 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3981 space seen by that current target.
3982 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3983 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3984 are examples; and there are many more.
3985
3986 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3987
3988 @deffn Command {target current}
3989 Returns the name of the current target.
3990 @end deffn
3991
3992 @deffn Command {target names}
3993 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3994 @example
3995 foreach t [target names] @{
3996 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3997 @}
3998 @end example
3999 @end deffn
4000
4001 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4002 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4003
4004 @deffn Command targets [name]
4005 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4006 command names are singular.}
4007
4008 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4009 targets in a user friendly form.
4010
4011 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4012 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4013 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4014 @end deffn
4015
4016 @section Target CPU Types
4017 @cindex target type
4018 @cindex CPU type
4019
4020 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4021 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4022 when calling @command{target create}.
4023 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4024 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4025 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4026 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4027 what core-specific commands may be available
4028 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4029 and more.
4030
4031 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4032 since there's a command to list them.
4033
4034 @anchor{targettypes}
4035 @deffn Command {target types}
4036 Lists all supported target types.
4037 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4038
4039 @itemize @bullet
4040 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4041 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4042 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4043 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4044 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4045 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4046 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4047 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4048 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4049 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4050 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4051 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4052 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4053 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4054 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4055 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4056 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4057 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4058 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4059 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4060 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4061 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4062 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4063 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4064 @itemize @minus
4065 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4066 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4067 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4068 @end itemize
4069 And two debug interfaces cores:
4070 @itemize @minus
4071 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4072 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4073 @end itemize
4074 @end itemize
4075 @end deffn
4076
4077 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4078 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4079 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4080 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4081 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4082 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4083 reflect design generations;
4084 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4085 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4086
4087 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4088 @section Target Configuration
4089
4090 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4091 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4092 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4093 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4094 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4095
4096 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4097 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4098 optional parts.
4099 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4100 command, created as part of target creation.
4101
4102 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4103 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4104 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4105 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4106 to be much more board-specific.
4107 The key steps you use might look something like this
4108
4109 @example
4110 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4111 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4112 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4113 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4114 @end example
4115
4116 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4117 on-chip SRAM.
4118 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4119 writes to target memory;
4120 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4121 GDB memory checksumming;
4122 and more.
4123
4124 @quotation Warning
4125 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4126 inaccessible when application code
4127 (such as an operating system)
4128 enables or disables the MMU.
4129 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4130 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4131 easy access to other addresses needed.
4132 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4133 @end quotation
4134
4135 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4136 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4137 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4138 controllers.
4139 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4140 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4141 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4142
4143 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4144 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4145 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4146 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4147 purposes including additional configuration.
4148
4149 @itemize @bullet
4150 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4151 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4152 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4153 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4154
4155 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4156 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4157 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4158 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4159 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4160 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4161 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4162
4163 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4164 @end itemize
4165 @end deffn
4166
4167 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4168 The options accepted by this command may also be
4169 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4170 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4171 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4172
4173 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4174 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4175 and changing its endianness.
4176
4177 @itemize @bullet
4178
4179 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4180 used to access this target.
4181
4182 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4183 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4184
4185 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4186 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4187 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4188 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4189 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4190 same event name assigns only one handler.
4191
4192 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4193 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4194 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4195 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4196 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4197 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4198 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4199
4200 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4201 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4202 or virtual address is being used.
4203
4204 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4205 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4206
4207 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4208 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4209 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4210 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4211 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4212
4213 @anchor{rtostype}
4214 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4215 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4216 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4217 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4218
4219 @end itemize
4220 @end deffn
4221
4222 @section Other $target_name Commands
4223 @cindex object command
4224
4225 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4226 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4227
4228 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4229 Once a button is created a button
4230 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4231 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4232 configure it like this:
4233
4234 @example
4235 # Create
4236 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4237 # Modify
4238 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4239 # Query
4240 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4241 # Report
4242 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4243 @end example
4244
4245 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4246 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4247
4248 @example
4249 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4250 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4251 @end example
4252
4253 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4254
4255 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4256 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4257 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4258 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4259 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4260 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4261 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4262 They are not otherwise documented here.
4263 @end deffn
4264
4265 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4266 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4267 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4268 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4269 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4270 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4271 the target side uses raw memory.
4272
4273 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4274 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4275 The script orientation comes from working with data
4276 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4277 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4278 and neither store nor return those values.
4279
4280 @itemize
4281 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4282 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4283 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4284 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4285 @end itemize
4286 @end deffn
4287
4288 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4289 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4290 @command{$target_name configure}
4291 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4292 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4293 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4294 There are a few special cases:
4295
4296 @itemize @bullet
4297 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4298 event named @var{event_name}.
4299 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4300 two parameters.
4301 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4302 This is a special case because this is set using
4303 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4304 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4305 @end itemize
4306
4307 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4308 all the targets you might use something like this:
4309
4310 @example
4311 foreach name [target names] @{
4312 set y [$name cget -endian]
4313 set z [$name cget -type]
4314 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4315 $x $name $y $z]
4316 @}
4317 @end example
4318 @end deffn
4319
4320 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4321 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4322 Displays the current target state:
4323 @code{debug-running},
4324 @code{halted},
4325 @code{reset},
4326 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4327 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4331 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4332 currently associated with this target.
4333 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4334 @end deffn
4335
4336 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4337 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4338 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4339 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4340 @end deffn
4341
4342 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4343 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4344 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4345 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4346 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4347 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4348 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4349 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4350 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4351 @end deffn
4352
4353 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4354 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4355 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4356 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4357 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4358 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4359 @end deffn
4360
4361 @anchor{targetevents}
4362 @section Target Events
4363 @cindex target events
4364 @cindex events
4365 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4366 For example:
4367 @itemize @bullet
4368 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4369 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4370 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4371 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4372 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4373 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4374 to set up system clocks or
4375 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4376 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4377 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4378 @end itemize
4379
4380 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4381 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4382 @command{target create ... -event}.
4383
4384 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4385 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4386 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4387
4388 @example
4389 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4390 echo "Reset..."
4391 reset halt
4392 @}
4393 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4394 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4395 echo "Reset..."
4396 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4397 # we need a reset init.
4398 reset init
4399 @}
4400 @end example
4401
4402 The following target events are defined:
4403
4404 @itemize @bullet
4405 @item @b{debug-halted}
4406 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4407 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4408 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4409 @item @b{early-halted}
4410 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4411 @item @b{examine-start}
4412 @* Before target examine is called.
4413 @item @b{examine-end}
4414 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4415 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4416 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4417 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4418 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4419 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4420 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4421 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4422 @* When GDB disconnects
4423 @item @b{gdb-end}
4424 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4425 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4426 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4427 @code{reset init})
4428 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4429 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4430 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4431 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4432 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4433 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4434 @item @b{gdb-start}
4435 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4436 @item @b{halted}
4437 @* The target has halted
4438 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4439 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4440 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4441 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4442 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4443 @item @b{reset-assert}
4444 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4445 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4446 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4447 it instead of asserting SRST.
4448 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4449 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4450 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4451 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4452 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4453 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4454 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4455 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4456 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4457 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4458 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4459 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4460 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4461 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4462 released on the scan chain.
4463 @item @b{reset-end}
4464 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4465 @ignore
4466 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4467 @* Currently not used
4468 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4469 @* Currently not used
4470 @end ignore
4471 @item @b{reset-init}
4472 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4473 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4474
4475 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4476 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4477 multiplexing, and so on.
4478 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4479 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4480 @item @b{reset-start}
4481 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4482 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4483
4484 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4485 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4486 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4487 @ignore
4488 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4489 @* Currently not used
4490 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4491 @* Currently not used
4492 @end ignore
4493 @item @b{resume-start}
4494 @* Before any target is resumed
4495 @item @b{resume-end}
4496 @* After all targets have resumed
4497 @item @b{resumed}
4498 @* Target has resumed
4499 @item @b{trace-config}
4500 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4501 @end itemize
4502
4503 @node Flash Commands
4504 @chapter Flash Commands
4505
4506 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4507 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4508 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4509 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4510 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4511 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4512 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4513 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4514 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4515
4516 Flash Steps:
4517 @enumerate
4518 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4519 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4520 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4521 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4522 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4523 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4524 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4525 @item GDB Flashing
4526 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4527 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4528 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4529 @end enumerate
4530
4531 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4532 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4533 so that it can't boot.
4534 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4535 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4536
4537 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4538 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4539 @cindex flash configuration
4540
4541 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4542 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4543 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4544 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4545 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4546 see the driver-specific documentation.
4547
4548 @itemize @bullet
4549 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4550 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4551 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4552 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4553 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4554 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4555 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4556 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4557 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4558 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4559 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4560 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4561 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4562 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4563 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4564 commands to the flash controller.
4565 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4566 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4567 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4568 for more information.
4569 @end itemize
4570 @quotation Note
4571 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4572 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4573 @end quotation
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4577 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4578 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4579 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4580 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4581 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4582 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4583 @end deffn
4584
4585 @deffn Command {flash list}
4586 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4587 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4588 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4589 @end deffn
4590
4591 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4592 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4593 depends on the flash type.
4594 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4595 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4596 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4597 but most don't bother.
4598 @end deffn
4599
4600 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4601 @cindex flash erasing
4602 @cindex flash reading
4603 @cindex flash writing
4604 @cindex flash programming
4605 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4606
4607 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4608 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4609 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4610 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4611 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4612
4613 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4614 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4615 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4616 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4617 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4618
4619 @quotation Note
4620 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4621 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4622 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4623 back to a flash bank.
4624 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4625 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4626 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4627 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4628 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4629 @end quotation
4630
4631 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4632 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4633 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4634 disabled first.
4635 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4636 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4637 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4638
4639 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4640 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4641 up to and including @var{last}.
4642 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4643 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4644 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4645 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4646 @end deffn
4647
4648 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4649 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4650 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4651 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4652 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4653 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4654 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4655 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4656 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4657 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4658 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4659 before erase starts.
4660 @end deffn
4661
4662 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4663 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4664 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4665 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4666 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4667 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4668 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4669 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4670 before issuing this command.
4671 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4672 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4673 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4674 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4675 @end deffn
4676 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4677
4678 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4679 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4680 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4681 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4682 @end deffn
4683
4684 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4685 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4686 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4688 @end deffn
4689
4690 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4691 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4692 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4693 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4694 @end deffn
4695
4696 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4697 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4698 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4699 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4700 to the base address for each section in the image.
4701 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4702 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4703 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4704 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4705 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4706 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4707 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4708 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4709 each image section.
4710
4711 @quotation Warning
4712 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4713 data you want to preserve.
4714 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4715 sections might be erased with no notice.
4716 @itemize
4717 @item
4718 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4719 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4720 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4721 @item
4722 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4723 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4724 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4725 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4726 @end itemize
4727 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4728 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4729 @end quotation
4730
4731 @end deffn
4732
4733 @section Other Flash commands
4734 @cindex flash protection
4735
4736 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4737 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4738 and display that status.
4739 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4740 @end deffn
4741
4742 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4743 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4744 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4745 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4746 and possibly stale information.
4747 @end deffn
4748
4749 @anchor{flashprotect}
4750 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4751 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4752 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4753 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4754 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4755 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4756 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4757 @end deffn
4758
4759 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4760 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4761 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4762 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4763 @end deffn
4764
4765 @anchor{program}
4766 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4767 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4768 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4769 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4770 @end deffn
4771
4772 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4773 @section Flash Driver List
4774 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4775 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4776 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4777
4778 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4779 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4780 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4781
4782 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4783
4784 @itemize
4785 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4786 @end itemize
4787
4788 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4789 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4790 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4791 @example
4792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4793 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4794 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4795 @end example
4796 @end deffn
4797
4798 @subsection External Flash
4799
4800 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4801 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4802 @cindex CFI
4803 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4804 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4805 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4806 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4807 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4808 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4809 configure a bus and its timings), or
4810 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4811 on the flash chip.
4812 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4813 speed up operation.
4814
4815 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4816
4817 @itemize
4818 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4819 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4820 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4821 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4822 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4823 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4824 @end itemize
4825
4826 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4827 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4828
4829 @example
4830 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4831 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4832 @end example
4833
4834 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4835 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4836 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4837
4838 @example
4839 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4840 @end example
4841
4842 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4843 @end deffn
4844
4845 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4846 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4847 @cindex SPI
4848 @cindex jtagspi
4849 @cindex bscan_spi
4850 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4851 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4852 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4853 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4854 accessed through JTAG.
4855
4856 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4857 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4858 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4859 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4860 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4861 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4862
4863 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4864 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4865 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4866 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4867 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4868 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4869 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4870 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4871
4872 @itemize
4873 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4874 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4875 @var{USER1} instruction.
4876 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4877 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4878 @end itemize
4879
4880 @example
4881 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4882 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4883 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4885 @end example
4886 @end deffn
4887
4888 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4889 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4890 @cindex SPIFI
4891 @cindex lpcspifi
4892 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4893 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4894 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4895
4896 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4897 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4898 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4899 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4900 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4901
4902 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4903 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4904 are configured by the driver.
4905
4906 @example
4907 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4908 @end example
4909
4910 @end deffn
4911
4912 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4913 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4914 @cindex SMI
4915 @cindex stmsmi
4916 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4917 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4918 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4919 SPI flash devices.
4920 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4921 flash devices can be connected.
4922
4923 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4924 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4925 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4926 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4927 the flash content.
4928
4929 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4930 to identify the memory bank.
4931 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4932 flash size, are detected automatically.
4933
4934 @example
4935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4936 @end example
4937
4938 @end deffn
4939
4940 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4941 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4942 Microcontroller platform.
4943
4944 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4945 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4946
4947 @example
4948 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4949 @end example
4950
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4954
4955 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4956 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4957 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4958 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4959 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4960 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4961
4962 @example
4963 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4964 @end example
4965 @end deffn
4966
4967 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4968 @cindex ambiqmicro
4969 @cindex apollo
4970 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4971 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4972 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4973 with the target using SWD.
4974
4975 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4976 the device class of the MCU.
4977 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4978 to set up the flash banks.
4979 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4980 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4981
4982 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4983 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4984 and the second bank starts after the first.
4985
4986 @example
4987 # Flash bank 0
4988 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4989 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4990 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4991 @end example
4992
4993 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
4994 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
4995 are available to the user.
4996
4997 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
4998
4999 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5000 Erase entire bank.
5001 @end deffn
5002 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5003 Erase device pages.
5004 @end deffn
5005 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5006 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5007 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5008 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5009 the flash.
5010 @end deffn
5011 @end deffn
5012
5013 @anchor{at91samd}
5014 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5015 @cindex at91samd
5016 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5017 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5018 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5019
5020 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5021 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5022 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5023 processor to be halted.
5024 @end deffn
5025
5026 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5027 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5028 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5029 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5030 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5031 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5032
5033 @example
5034 at91samd set-security enable
5035 @end example
5036 @end deffn
5037
5038 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5039 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5040 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5041 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5042 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5043 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5044 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5045 in order to disable this feature.
5046
5047 @example
5048 at91samd eeprom
5049 at91samd eeprom 1024
5050 @end example
5051 @end deffn
5052
5053 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5054 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5055 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5056 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5057 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5058 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5059
5060 @example
5061 at91samd bootloader
5062 at91samd bootloader 16384
5063 @end example
5064 @end deffn
5065
5066 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5067 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5068 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5069 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5070 @end deffn
5071
5072 @end deffn
5073
5074 @anchor{at91sam3}
5075 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5076 @cindex at91sam3
5077 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5078 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5079 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5080 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5081 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5082 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5083 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5084 chips are confirmed.}
5085
5086 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5087 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5088 the following fixed locations:
5089
5090 @example
5091 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5092 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5093 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5094 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5095 @end example
5096
5097 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5098 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5099 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5100
5101 @itemize
5102 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5103 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5104 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5105 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5106 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5107 @end itemize
5108
5109 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5110
5111 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5112 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5113 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5114 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5115 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5116 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5117 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5118
5119 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5120 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5121 @end deffn
5122
5123 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5124 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5125 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5126 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5127 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5128 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5129 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5130 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5131 @end deffn
5132
5133 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5134 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5135 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5136 @end deffn
5137 @end deffn
5138
5139 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5140 @cindex at91sam4
5141 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5142 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5143 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5144 @end deffn
5145
5146 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5147 @cindex at91sam4l
5148 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5149 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5150 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5151
5152 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5153 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5154 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5155 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5156 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5157 @end deffn
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5161 @cindex atsamv
5162 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5163 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5164 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5165 @end deffn
5166
5167 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5168 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5169 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5170 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5171 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5172
5173 @example
5174 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5175 @end example
5176
5177 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5178 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5179
5180 @itemize
5181 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5182 @item @var{banks}
5183 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5184 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5185 @item @var{pages_size}
5186 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5187 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5188 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5189 @end itemize
5190
5191 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5192 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5193 will be autoconfigured.
5194 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5195
5196 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5197 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5198 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5199 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5200 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5201
5202 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5203 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5204 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5205 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5206 are not truly general purpose).
5207 @quotation Note
5208 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5209 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5210 @end quotation
5211 @end deffn
5212 @end deffn
5213
5214 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5215 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5216 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5217 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5221 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5222 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5223 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5224 autoconfigures itself.
5225 @example
5226 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5227 @end example
5228 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5229 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5230 this via the following command:
5231 @example
5232 efm32 debuglock num
5233 @end example
5234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5235 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5236 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5237 supported.}
5238 @end deffn
5239
5240 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5241 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5242 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5243 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5244 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5245 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5246 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5247
5248 @example
5249 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5250 @end example
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5254 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5255 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5256 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5257 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5258 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5259 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5260 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5261 characters) ignored.
5262
5263 @example
5264 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5265 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5266 @end example
5267 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5268 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5269 @end deffn
5270
5271 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5272 @cindex kinetis
5273 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5274 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5275 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5276 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5277
5278 @example
5279 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5280 @end example
5281
5282 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5283 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5284 @end deffn
5285
5286 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5287 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5288 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5289 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5290 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5291 @end deffn
5292
5293 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5294 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5295 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5296 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5297 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5298
5299 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5300 Program Partition command.
5301
5302 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5303 Reset the device after partition setting.
5304
5305 Show partition size:
5306 @example
5307 kinetis nvm_partition info
5308 @end example
5309
5310 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5311 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5312 @example
5313 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5314 @end example
5315
5316 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5317 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5318 @example
5319 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5320 @end example
5321 @end deffn
5322
5323 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5324 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5325 Command disables watchdog timer.
5326 @end deffn
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5330 @cindex kinetis_ke
5331 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5332 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5333 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5334 autoconfigures itself.
5335
5336 @example
5337 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5338 @end example
5339
5340 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5341 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5342 @end deffn
5343
5344 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5345 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5346 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5347 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5348 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5349 @end deffn
5350
5351 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5352 Command disables watchdog timer.
5353 @end deffn
5354 @end deffn
5355
5356 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5357 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5358 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5359 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5360 microcontroller families from NXP.
5361
5362 @quotation Note
5363 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5364 driver:
5365 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5366 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5367 @end quotation
5368
5369 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5370 which must appear in the following order:
5371
5372 @itemize
5373 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5374 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5375 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5376 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5377 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5378 LPC43x[2357])
5379 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5380 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5381 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5382 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5383 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5384 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5385 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5386 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5387 at which the core is running
5388 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5389 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5390 @quotation Note
5391 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5392 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5393 However, if you do provide it,
5394 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5395 @end quotation
5396 @end itemize
5397
5398 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5399
5400 @example
5401 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5402 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5403 @end example
5404
5405 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5406 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5407 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5408 @end deffn
5409 @end deffn
5410
5411 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5412 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5413 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5414 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5415 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5416 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5417
5418 @example
5419 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5420 @end example
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5424 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5425 from NXP.
5426
5427 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5428 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5429 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5430 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5431 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5432 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5433 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5434 you start the PLL.
5435
5436 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5437
5438 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5439 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5440 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5441
5442 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5443 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5444 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5445 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5446 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5447 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5448 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5449
5450 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5451 @example
5452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5453 @end example
5454
5455 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5456 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5457 @code{flash banks} command.
5458
5459 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5460 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5461 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5462 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5463 a known signature.
5464 Example:
5465 @example
5466 lpc2900 signature 0
5467 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5468 @end example
5469 @end deffn
5470
5471 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5472 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5473 saves it to a file in binary format.
5474 Example:
5475 @example
5476 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5477 @end example
5478 @end deffn
5479
5480 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5481 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5482 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5483 command:
5484
5485 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5486 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5487 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5488 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5489
5490 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5491 Example:
5492 @example
5493 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5494 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5495 @end example
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5499 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5500 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5501 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5502 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5503 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5504 912 bytes.
5505 @quotation Attention
5506 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5507 @end quotation
5508 Example:
5509 @example
5510 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5511 @end example
5512 @end deffn
5513
5514 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5515 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5516 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5517 after the next power cycle.
5518 @quotation Attention
5519 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5520 @end quotation
5521 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5522 Example:
5523 @example
5524 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5525 flash info 0
5526 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5527 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5528 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5529 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5530 @end example
5531 @end deffn
5532
5533 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5534 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5535 effective after the next power cycle.
5536 @quotation Attention
5537 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5538 @end quotation
5539 Examples:
5540 @example
5541 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5542 @end example
5543 @end deffn
5544 @end deffn
5545
5546 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5547 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5548 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5549 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5550
5551 @example
5552 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5553 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5554 @end example
5555
5556 @itemize @bullet
5557 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5558 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5559 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5560 @end itemize
5561
5562 Example usage:
5563 @example
5564 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5565 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5566 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5567 @} else @{
5568 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5569 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5570 @}
5571 @end example
5572 @end deffn
5573
5574 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5575 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5576 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5577 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5578 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5579 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5580 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5581 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5582 also have division into regions: main and info.
5583 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5584 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5585
5586 @example
5587 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5588 @end example
5589
5590 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5591
5592 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5593 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5597 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5598 @end deffn
5599
5600 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5601 Erase all userflash including info region.
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5605 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5606 @end deffn
5607
5608 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5609 Check sectors protect.
5610 @end deffn
5611
5612 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5613 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5614 @end deffn
5615
5616 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5617 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5621 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5622 @end deffn
5623
5624 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5625 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5629 Show information about flash driver.
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5635 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5636 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5637
5638 @example
5639 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5640 @end example
5641
5642 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5643
5644 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5645 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5646 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5647 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5648 code.
5649 @end deffn
5650
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5654 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5655 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5656
5657 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5658 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5659 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5660 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5661
5662 @example
5663 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5664 @end example
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5668 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5669 and integrate flash memory.
5670
5671 @example
5672 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5673 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5674 @end example
5675
5676 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5677 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5678 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5679 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5680 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5681 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5682 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5683 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5684 @end deffn
5685 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5686 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5687 This will remove any Code Protection.
5688 @end deffn
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5692 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5693 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5694 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5695 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5696
5697 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5698 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5699
5700 @example
5701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5702 @end example
5703
5704 psoc4-specific commands
5705 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5706 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5707
5708 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5709 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5710
5711 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5712 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5713 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5714
5715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5716 @end deffn
5717
5718 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5719 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5720
5721 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5722 @end deffn
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5726 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5727 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5728 and SWD interface.
5729 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5730 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5731
5732 @example
5733 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5734 @end example
5735
5736 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5737
5738 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5739 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5740 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5741 @end deffn
5742
5743 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5744 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5745 @end deffn
5746 @end deffn
5747
5748 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5749 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5750 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5751 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5752 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5753 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5754 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5755 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5756
5757 @example
5758 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5759 @end example
5760
5761 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5762 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5763 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5764 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5765 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5766 disabled.
5767
5768 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5769 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5770 @quotation Warning
5771 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5772 applied to all of them.
5773 @end quotation
5774 @end deffn
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5778 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5779 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5780 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5781 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5782
5783 @example
5784 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5785 @end example
5786
5787 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5788 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5789 the flash driver.
5790
5791 @example
5792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5793 @end example
5794
5795 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5796 as per the following example.
5797 @example
5798 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5799 @end example
5800
5801 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5802 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5803 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5804 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5805 are defined:
5806
5807 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5808 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5809 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5810 @end deffn
5811
5812 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5813 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5814 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5815 @end deffn
5816
5817 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5818 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5819 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5820 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5824 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5825 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5826 @end deffn
5827 @end deffn
5828
5829 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5830 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5831 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5832 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5833 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5834
5835 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5836 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5837 the flash driver.
5838
5839 @example
5840 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5841 @end example
5842
5843 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5844
5845 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5846 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5847 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5848 @end deffn
5849
5850 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5851 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5852 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5853 @end deffn
5854
5855 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5856 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5857 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5861 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5862 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5863 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5864 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5865 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5866 @end deffn
5867 @end deffn
5868
5869 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5870 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5871 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5872 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5873 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5874
5875 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5876 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5877 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5878 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5879 second bank.
5880
5881 @example
5882 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5883 @end example
5884
5885 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5886
5887 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5888 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5889 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5890 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5891 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5892 @end deffn
5893 @end deffn
5894
5895 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5896 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5897 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5898 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5899 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5900
5901 @example
5902 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5903 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5904 @end example
5905
5906 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5907 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5908 for the specified flash bank.
5909 @end deffn
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5913 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5914 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5915 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5916 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5917
5918 @example
5919 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5920 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5921 @end example
5922
5923 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5924 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5925 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5926
5927 @itemize @bullet
5928 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5929 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5930 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5931 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5932 @end itemize
5933 @end deffn
5934
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5938 @cindex str9xpec
5939
5940 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5941 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5942 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5943 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5944
5945 Here is some background info to help
5946 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5947 the str9:
5948 @enumerate
5949 @item
5950 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5951 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5952 @item
5953 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5954 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5955 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5956 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5957 @end enumerate
5958
5959 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5960 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5961 configured for flash bank 0.
5962 @example
5963 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5964 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5965 jtag_reset 0 1
5966 # turn off target polling
5967 poll off
5968 # disable str9 core
5969 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5970 # read option bytes
5971 str9xpec options_read 0
5972 # re-enable str9 core
5973 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5974 poll on
5975 reset halt
5976 @end example
5977 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5978 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5979 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5980 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5981
5982 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5983
5984 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5985 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5986 @end deffn
5987
5988 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5989 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5990 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5994 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5995 erase the device.
5996 @end deffn
5997
5998 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5999 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6000 @end deffn
6001
6002 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6003 Configure str9 boot bank.
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6007 Configure str9 lvd source.
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6011 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6015 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6019 Read str9 option bytes.
6020 @end deffn
6021
6022 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6023 Write str9 option bytes.
6024 @end deffn
6025
6026 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6027 unlock str9 device.
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @end deffn
6031
6032 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6033 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6034 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6035 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6036
6037 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6038
6039 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6040 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6044 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6045 @end deffn
6046
6047 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6048 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6049 the flash clock.
6050 @end deffn
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6054 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6055 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6059 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6060 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6061
6062 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6063
6064 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6065 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6066 @end deffn
6067
6068 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6069 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6070 @end deffn
6071
6072 @end deffn
6073
6074 @section NAND Flash Commands
6075 @cindex NAND
6076
6077 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6078 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6079 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6080
6081 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6082 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6083 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6084 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6085 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6086 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6087
6088 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6089 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6090 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6091 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6092 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6093 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6094 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6095 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6096 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6097 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6098
6099 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6100 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6101 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6102 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6103 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6104 every 512 bytes of data.
6105
6106 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6107 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6108 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6109 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6110 ECC mode is used.
6111
6112 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6113 @enumerate
6114 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6115 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6116 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6117 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6118 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6119 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6120 to access that device.
6121 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6122 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6123 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6124 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6125 de-brick a board.
6126 @end enumerate
6127
6128 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6129 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6130 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6131 are only 32 bits wide.
6132 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6133 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6134 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6135 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6136
6137 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6138 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6139 @cindex NAND configuration
6140
6141 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6142 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6143 OpenOCD has initialized.
6144
6145 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6146 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6147 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6148 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6149 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6150 they were a single (larger) device.
6151 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6152 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6153
6154 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6155 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6156 configuration files, not interactively.
6157
6158 @itemize @bullet
6159 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6160 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6161 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6162 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6163 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6164 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6165 commands to the NAND controller.
6166 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6167 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6168 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6169 for more information.
6170 @end itemize
6171 @end deffn
6172
6173 @deffn Command {nand list}
6174 Prints a summary of each device declared
6175 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6176 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6177 @example
6178 > nand list
6179 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6180 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6181 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6182 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6183 >
6184 @end example
6185 @end deffn
6186
6187 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6188 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6189 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6190 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6191 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6192 it with most other NAND commands.
6193 @end deffn
6194
6195 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6196
6197 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6198 @cindex NAND reading
6199 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6200 starting at the specified offset.
6201 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6202
6203 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6204 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6205
6206 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6207 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6208 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6209
6210 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6211 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6212 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6213 method which handled that error correction.
6214
6215 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6216 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6217 @itemize @bullet
6218 @item no oob_* parameter
6219 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6220 @item @code{oob_raw}
6221 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6222 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6223 spare areas associated with each data page.
6224 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6225 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6226 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6227 @item @code{oob_only}
6228 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6229 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6230 spare areas associated with each data page.
6231 @end itemize
6232 @end deffn
6233
6234 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6235 @cindex NAND erasing
6236 @cindex NAND programming
6237 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6238 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6239 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6240 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6241 If those parameters are not specified,
6242 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6243 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6244
6245 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6246 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6247 block marker.
6248 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6249 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6250 @end deffn
6251
6252 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6253 @cindex NAND writing
6254 @cindex NAND programming
6255 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6256 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6257 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6258 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6259
6260 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6261 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6262
6263 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6264 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6265 past the end of the device.
6266 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6267 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6268 if that's being written.)
6269
6270 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6271 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6272 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6273
6274 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6275 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6276 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6277 @itemize @bullet
6278 @item no oob_* parameter
6279 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6280 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6281 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6282 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6283 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6284 @item @code{oob_only}
6285 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6286 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6287 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6288 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6289 @item @code{oob_raw}
6290 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6291 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6292 un-altered OOB.
6293 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6294 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6295 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6296 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6297 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6298 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6299 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6300 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6301 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6302 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6303 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6304 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6305 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6306 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6307 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6308 @end itemize
6309 @end deffn
6310
6311 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6312 @cindex NAND verification
6313 @cindex NAND programming
6314 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6315 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6316 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6317
6318 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6319 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6320
6321 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6322 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6323 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6324 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6325 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6326
6327 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6328 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6329 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6330
6331 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6332 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6333 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6334 be removed in a future release.
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @subsection Other NAND commands
6338 @cindex NAND other commands
6339
6340 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6341 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6342 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6343 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6344 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6345 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6346 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6347 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6348
6349 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6350 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6351 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6355 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6356 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6357 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6358 status for each block.
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6362 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6363 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6364
6365 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6366 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6367 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6368 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6369 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6370
6371 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6372 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6373 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6374 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6375 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6376 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6377 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6378 @end deffn
6379
6380 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6381 @subsection NAND Driver List
6382 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6383 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6384 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6385
6386 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6387 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6388 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6389 address of the ECC controller.
6390 @example
6391 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6392 @end example
6393 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6394 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6395 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6396 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6397 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6398 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6399 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6400 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6401 @end deffn
6402 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6403 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6404 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6405 @end deffn
6406
6407 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6408 properly configured for input or output.
6409 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6410 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6411 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6412 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6413 @end deffn
6414 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6415 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6416 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6417 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6418 @end deffn
6419 @end deffn
6420
6421 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6422 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6423 chips from Texas Instruments.
6424 It takes three extra parameters:
6425 address of the NAND chip;
6426 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6427 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6428 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6429 @example
6430 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6431 @end example
6432 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6433 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6434 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6435 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6436 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6437 @end deffn
6438
6439 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6440 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6441 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6442 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6443 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6444 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6445 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6446 @end deffn
6447
6448 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6449 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6450 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6451 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6452 @end deffn
6453 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6454
6455 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6456 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6457 should work for this chip aswell.
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6461 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6462 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6463 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6464 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6465 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6466 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6467 @example
6468 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6469 @end example
6470 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6471 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6472 without parameter query status.
6473 @end deffn
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6477 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6478 parameter: the address of the controller.
6479 @example
6480 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6481 @end example
6482 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6483 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6484 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6485 change any behavior.
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6489 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6490 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6491 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6492 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6493 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6494 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6495 specialized commands.
6496 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6497 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6498 change any behavior.
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @section mFlash
6502
6503 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6504 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6505
6506 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6507 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6508 address @var{base}.
6509 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6510 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6511
6512 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6513
6514 @example
6515 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6516 @end example
6517
6518 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6519
6520 @example
6521 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6522 @end example
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @subsection mFlash commands
6526 @cindex mFlash commands
6527
6528 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6529 Configure mflash PLL.
6530 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6531 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6532 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6533 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6537 Configure bootable option.
6538 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6539 (4kB) for boot.
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6543 Configure storage information.
6544 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6545 written.
6546 @end deffn
6547
6548 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6549 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6550 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6551 @end deffn
6552
6553 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6554 Probe mflash.
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6558 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6559 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6560 @end deffn
6561
6562 @node Flash Programming
6563 @chapter Flash Programming
6564
6565 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6566 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6567 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6568
6569 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6570 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6571
6572 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6573 @enumerate
6574 @item 'init' is executed.
6575 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6576 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6577 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6578 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6579 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6580 @end enumerate
6581
6582 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6583
6584 @example
6585 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6586 # are optional parameters
6587 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6588 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6589
6590 # binary files need the flash address passing
6591 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6592 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6593 @end example
6594
6595 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6596 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6597 @cindex PLD
6598 @cindex FPGA
6599
6600 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6601 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6602 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6603 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6604 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6605 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6606 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6607
6608 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6609
6610 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6611 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6612 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6613
6614 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6615 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6616
6617 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6618 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6619 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6620 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6621 behavior.
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6625 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6626 @end deffn
6627
6628 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6629 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6630 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6631 @end deffn
6632
6633 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6634
6635 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6636 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6637 that particular type of PLD.
6638
6639 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6640 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6641 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6642
6643 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6644 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6645 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6646
6647 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6648 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6649 for FPGA @var{num}.
6650 @end deffn
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @node General Commands
6654 @chapter General Commands
6655 @cindex commands
6656
6657 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6658 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6659 commands are documented elsewhere.
6660
6661 Intent:
6662 @itemize @bullet
6663 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6664 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6665 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6666 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6667
6668 @item @b{From the human}
6669 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6670 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6671
6672 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6673 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6674 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6675
6676 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6677 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6678 port is 5555.
6679 @end itemize
6680
6681
6682 @section Daemon Commands
6683
6684 @deffn {Command} exit
6685 Exits the current telnet session.
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6689 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6690 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6691 Not every command provides helptext.
6692
6693 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6694 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6695 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6696 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6700 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6701 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6702 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6703 Useful in connection with script files
6704 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6708 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6709 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6710 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @anchor{debuglevel}
6714 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6715 @cindex message level
6716 Display debug level.
6717 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6718 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6719 Level 0 is error messages only;
6720 level 1 adds warnings;
6721 level 2 adds informational messages;
6722 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6723 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6724 the command line along with the location of that log
6725 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6726 @xref{Running}.
6727 @end deffn
6728
6729 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6730 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6731 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6732 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6733 @example
6734 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6735 @end example
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6739 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6740 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6741 @end deffn
6742
6743 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6744 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6745 @end deffn
6746
6747 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6748 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6749 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6750 @end deffn
6751
6752 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6753 @section Target State handling
6754 @cindex reset
6755 @cindex halt
6756 @cindex target initialization
6757
6758 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6759 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6760 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6761 a current target which is used to perform the
6762 various operations. The current target may be changed
6763 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6764 target which should become current.
6765
6766 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6767 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6768 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6769 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6770 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6771
6772 @emph{With no arguments}:
6773 list all available registers for the current target,
6774 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6775 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6776 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6777 are flagged as such.
6778
6779 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6780 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6781 bypassing any internal cache.
6782
6783 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6784 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6785 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6786 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6787 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6788 relevant module will flush such values.
6789
6790 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6791 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6792
6793 @example
6794 > reg
6795 ===== ARM registers
6796 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6797 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6798 (2) r2 (/32)
6799 ...
6800 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6801 >
6802 @end example
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6806 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6807 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6808 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6809 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6810 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6811 (and enter debug mode).
6812 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6813
6814 @quotation Warning
6815 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6816 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6817 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6818 power mode by gating the core clock;
6819 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6820
6821 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6822 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6823 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6824 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6825 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6826 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6827
6828 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6829 work with a JTAG debugger.
6830 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6831 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6832 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6833 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6834 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6835 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6836 @end quotation
6837
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn Command resume [address]
6841 Resume the target at its current code position,
6842 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6843 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command step [address]
6847 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6848 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @anchor{resetcommand}
6852 @deffn Command reset
6853 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6854 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6855 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6856 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6857 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6858 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6859
6860 The optional parameter specifies what should
6861 happen after the reset.
6862 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6863 The other options will not work on all systems.
6864 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6865
6866 @itemize @minus
6867 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6868 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6869 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6870 @end itemize
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6874 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6875 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6876 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6877 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6878 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6879 state.
6880 @end deffn
6881
6882 @section I/O Utilities
6883
6884 These commands are available when
6885 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6886 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6887 notably the ZY1000.
6888 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6889
6890 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6891
6892 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6893 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6894 the text file @file{filename}.
6895 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6896 The last string is followed by a newline.
6897 @end deffn
6898
6899 @deffn Command cat filename
6900 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6904 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6905 into @file{dest_filename}.
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn Command ip
6909 @emph{No description provided.}
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn Command ls
6913 @emph{No description provided.}
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn Command mac
6917 @emph{No description provided.}
6918 @end deffn
6919
6920 @deffn Command meminfo
6921 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6922 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6923 @end deffn
6924
6925 @deffn Command peek
6926 @emph{No description provided.}
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn Command poke
6930 @emph{No description provided.}
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn Command rm filename
6934 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6935 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn Command trunc filename
6939 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6940 @end deffn
6941
6942 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6943 @section Memory access commands
6944 @cindex memory access
6945
6946 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6947 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6948 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6949 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6950
6951 @enumerate
6952 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6953 to change the current target.
6954 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6955 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6956 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6957 @end enumerate
6958
6959 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6960 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6961 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6962 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6963 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6964 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6965 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6966 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6967 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6968 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6969 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6970 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6971 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6972 @end deffn
6973
6974 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6975 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6976 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6977 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6978 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6979 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6980 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6981 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6982 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6983 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6984 @end deffn
6985
6986 @anchor{imageaccess}
6987 @section Image loading commands
6988 @cindex image loading
6989 @cindex image dumping
6990
6991 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6992 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6993 binary file named @var{filename}.
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6997 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6998 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7002 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7003 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7004 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7005 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7006 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7007 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7008 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7009 separately.
7010 @end deffn
7011
7012 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7013 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7014 The file format may optionally be specified
7015 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7016 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7017 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7018 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7019 @example
7020 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7021 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7022 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7023 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7024 $address $length
7025 @}
7026 @end example
7027 @end deffn
7028
7029 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7030 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7031 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7032 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7033 The file format may optionally be specified
7034 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7038 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7039 The file format may optionally be specified
7040 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7041 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7042 @end deffn
7043
7044
7045 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7046 @cindex breakpoint
7047 @cindex watchpoint
7048
7049 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7050 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7051 watchpoints.
7052 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7053
7054 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7055 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7056 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7057 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7058 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7059 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7060
7061 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7062 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7066 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7070 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7074 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7075 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7076 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7077 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7078 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7079 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7080 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7081 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7082 @end deffn
7083
7084 @section Misc Commands
7085
7086 @cindex profiling
7087 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7088 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7089 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7090 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7091 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7092 limit the address range.
7093 @end deffn
7094
7095 @deffn Command {version}
7096 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7097 @end deffn
7098
7099 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7100 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7101 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7105 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7106 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7107 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7108
7109 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7110 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7111 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7112 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7113
7114 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7115 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7116 @cindex tracing
7117 @cindex ETM
7118 @cindex ETB
7119
7120 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7121 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7122 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7123
7124 @itemize
7125 @item
7126 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7127 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7128 supports such an interface.
7129 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7130 and trace port support.)
7131 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7132 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7133 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7134 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7135 in the board-specific configuration file.
7136 @item
7137 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7138 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7139 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7140 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7141 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7142 @end itemize
7143
7144 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7145
7146 @quotation Issues
7147 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7148 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7149
7150 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7151 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7152 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7153 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7154 dummy trace port driver}.
7155
7156 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7157 as well as tracing only during specific states
7158 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7159
7160 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7161 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7162 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7163 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7164 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7165
7166 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7167 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7168 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7169 this original style of JTAG access.
7170 @end quotation
7171
7172 @subsection ETM Configuration
7173 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7174
7175 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7176 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7177 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7178
7179 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7180 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7181 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7182 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7183 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7184 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7185 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7186 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7187 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7188
7189 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7190 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7191 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7192
7193 @quotation Warning
7194 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7195 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7196 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7197 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7198 @end quotation
7199
7200 @quotation Note
7201 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7202 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7203 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7204 what CPU activities are traced.
7205 @end quotation
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @deffn Command {etm info}
7209 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7210 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7211 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7212 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7213 @end deffn
7214
7215 @deffn Command {etm status}
7216 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7217 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7218 Did trace data overflow?
7219 Was it triggered?
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7223 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7224 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7225 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7226 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7227
7228 @itemize
7229 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7230 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7231 The value is one of
7232 @option{none} (save nothing),
7233 @option{data} (save data),
7234 @option{address} (save addresses),
7235 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7236 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7237 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7238 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7239 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7240 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7241 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7242 trace stream without an image of the code.
7243 @end itemize
7244 @end deffn
7245
7246 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7247 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7248 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7249 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7250 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7251
7252 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7253 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7254 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7258
7259 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7260 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7261 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7262
7263 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7264 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7265 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7266 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7267 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7268 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7269 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7270
7271 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7272
7273 @itemize
7274 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7275 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7276 for instruction access within that function's body.
7277 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7278 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7279 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7280 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7281 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7282 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7283 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7284 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7285 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7286 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7287 @item @emph{... more}
7288 @end itemize
7289
7290 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7291 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7292
7293 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7294 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7295 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7299 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7300 @end deffn
7301
7302 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7303 Opens an image file.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7307 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn Command {etm start}
7311 Starts trace data collection.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7315 Stops trace data collection.
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7319 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7320
7321 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7322
7323 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7324 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7325 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7326 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7327 any trace data collection.}
7328 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7329 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7330 @end deffn
7331 @end deffn
7332
7333 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7334 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7335 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7336 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7337 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7338 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7339 @end deffn
7340 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7341 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7342 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7343 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7344 trace trigger becomes active.
7345
7346 @itemize
7347 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7348 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7349 afterwards.
7350 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7351 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7352 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7353 what caused that event to happen.
7354 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7355 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7356 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7357 how the event caused trouble.
7358 @end itemize
7359 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7365 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7366 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7367 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7368 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7369
7370 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7371 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7372
7373 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7374 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7375 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7379 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7383 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7384 @end deffn
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387
7388 @section Generic ARM
7389 @cindex ARM
7390
7391 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7392 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7393 commands that may be available.
7394
7395 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7396 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7397 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7398 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7399 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7400 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7401 @end deffn
7402
7403 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7404 @cindex disassemble
7405 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7406 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7407 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7408 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7409 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7410 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7411 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7412
7413 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7414 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7415 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7416 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7417 with a handful of exceptions.
7418 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7422 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7423 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7424 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7425 and using the MCR instruction.
7426 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7427 an ARM register.)
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7431 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7432 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7433 and the MRC instruction.
7434 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7435 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7436 an ARM register.)
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7440 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7441 core mode if necessary.
7442 @end deffn
7443
7444 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7445 @cindex ARM semihosting
7446 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7447
7448 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7449 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7450 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7451 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7452 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7453 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7457 @cindex ARMv4
7458 @cindex ARMv5
7459
7460 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7461 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7462 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7463 variant.
7464
7465 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7466 @cindex ARM7
7467 @cindex ARM9
7468
7469 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7470 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7471 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7472 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7473
7474 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7475 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7476 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7477 instead of breakpoints.
7478 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7479
7480 This should be
7481 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7482 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7483 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7484 @end deffn
7485
7486 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7487 @cindex DCC
7488 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7489 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7490 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7491
7492 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7493 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7494 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7495 @end deffn
7496
7497 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7498 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7499 that don't check completion of the operation.
7500 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7501
7502 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7503 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7504 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7508 @cindex ARM720T
7509
7510 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7511 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7512 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7513 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7514
7515 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7516 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7517 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7518
7519 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7520 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7521 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7525 @cindex ARM9
7526
7527 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7528 integer processors.
7529 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7530
7531 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7532 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7533 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7534 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7535
7536 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7537 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7538 @cindex vector_catch
7539 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7540 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7541 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7542 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7543 to those hardware vectors.
7544
7545 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7546 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7547 vector catch hardware to intercept
7548 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7549 @option{none} of them,
7550 or a list with one or more of the following:
7551 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7552 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7556 @cindex ARM920T
7557
7558 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7559 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7560 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7561 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7562 and ARM9 commands.
7563
7564 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7565 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7566 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7567 @end deffn
7568
7569 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7570 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7571 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7572 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7573 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7574 (Not all registers can be written.)
7575 @end deffn
7576
7577 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7578 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7579 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7580
7581 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7582 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7583 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7584 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7585 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7586 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7590 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7594 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7598 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7599
7600 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7601 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7602 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7603 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7604 and ARM9 commands.
7605
7606 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7607 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7608
7609 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7610 Print information about the caches found.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7614 @cindex ARM966E
7615
7616 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7617 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7618 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7619 and ARM9 commands.
7620
7621 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7622 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7623 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7624 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7625 ARM966E-S TRM.
7626 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7627 as required for BIST support.
7628 @end deffn
7629
7630 @subsection XScale specific commands
7631 @cindex XScale
7632
7633 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7634
7635 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7636 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7637 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7638 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7639 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7640 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7641 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7642
7643 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7644 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7645 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7646 the mini-IC.
7647
7648 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7649 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7650 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7651 code layout in memory:
7652 @example
7653 _vectors:
7654 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7655 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7656 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7657 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7658 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7659 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7660 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7661 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7662 .org 0x100
7663 .long real_reset_vector
7664 .long real_ui_handler
7665 .long real_swi_handler
7666 .long real_pf_abort
7667 .long real_data_abort
7668 .long 0 /* unused */
7669 .long real_irq_handler
7670 .long real_fiq_handler
7671 @end example
7672
7673 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7674 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7675 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7676 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7677 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7678 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7679 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7680 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7681 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7682 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7683 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7684 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7685 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7686 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7687 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7688 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7689 software.
7690
7691 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7692 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7693 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7694 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7695
7696 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7697 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7698 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7699 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7700 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7701 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7702 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7703 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7704 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7705
7706 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7707 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7708
7709 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7710 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7714 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7718 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7719 @end deffn
7720
7721 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7722 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7723 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7724 @end deffn
7725
7726 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7727 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7728 @end deffn
7729
7730 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7731 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7735 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7736 @end deffn
7737
7738 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7739 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7740 @end deffn
7741
7742 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7743 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7744 @end deffn
7745
7746 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7747 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7748 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7749 and modifying how it is emptied.
7750 @end deffn
7751
7752 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7753 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7754 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7755 The image @var{type} may be one of
7756 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7757 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7758 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7762 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7763 @cindex vector_catch
7764 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7765 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7766
7767 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7768 @example
7769 0x01 Trap Reset
7770 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7771 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7772 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7773 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7774 0x20 reserved
7775 0x40 Trap IRQ
7776 0x80 Trap FIQ
7777 @end example
7778 @end deffn
7779
7780 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7781 @cindex vector_table
7782
7783 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7784 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7785 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7786 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7787 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7788
7789 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7790
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7794 @cindex ARMv6
7795
7796 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7797 @cindex ARM11
7798
7799 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7800 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7801 which is enabled by default.
7802 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7803 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7804 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7805 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7806 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7807 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7811 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7812 which is enabled by default.
7813 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7814 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7815 @end deffn
7816
7817 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7818 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7819 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7820 they are disabled by default.
7821 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7822 @end deffn
7823
7824 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7825 @cindex vector_catch
7826 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7827 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7828 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7829
7830 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7831 for certain hardware events.
7832 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7833 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7834 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7835 @end deffn
7836
7837 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7838 @cindex ARMv7
7839
7840 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7841 @cindex Debug Access Port
7842 @cindex DAP
7843 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7844 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7845 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7846
7847 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7848 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7849 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7850 @end deffn
7851
7852 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
7853 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
7854 or set a new value @var{value}.
7855 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
7856 @end deffn
7857
7858 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7859 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7860 @end deffn
7861
7862 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7863 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7864 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7865 @end deffn
7866
7867 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7868 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7869 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7873 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7874 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7875 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7876 @end deffn
7877
7878 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7879 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7880 Defaulting to 0.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7884 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7885 Disabled by default
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888
7889 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7890 @cindex Cortex-A
7891
7892 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7893 display information about target caches
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7897 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7898 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7899 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7900 Defaults to 'off'.
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7904 Initialize core debug
7905 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7909 Disable SMP mode
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7913 Enable SMP mode
7914 @end deffn
7915
7916 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7917 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7918 @end deffn
7919
7920 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7921 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7925 configure l2x cache
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928
7929 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7930 @cindex Cortex-R
7931
7932 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7933 Initialize core debug
7934 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7935 @end deffn
7936
7937 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7938 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7939 @end deffn
7940
7941
7942 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7943 @cindex tracing
7944 @cindex SWO
7945 @cindex SWV
7946 @cindex TPIU
7947 @cindex ITM
7948 @cindex ETM
7949
7950 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7951 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7952 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7953
7954 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7955 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7956 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7957 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7958
7959 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7960 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7961 debugger adapter features.
7962
7963 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7964 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7965
7966 Command options:
7967 @itemize @minus
7968 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7969 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7970 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7971 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7972 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7973 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7974 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7975 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7976 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7977 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7978 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7979 coding;
7980 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7981 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7982 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7983 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7984 data is to be output via SWO;
7985 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7986 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7987 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7988 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7989 rate automatically.
7990 @end itemize
7991
7992 Example usage:
7993 @enumerate
7994 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7995 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7996 enough to:
7997 @example
7998 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7999 ...
8000 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8001 ...
8002 @end example
8003 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8004 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8005 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8006 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8007 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8008 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8009 @example
8010 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8011 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8012 @end example
8013 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8014 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8015 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8016 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8017 @example
8018 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8019 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8020 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8021 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8022 @end example
8023 @end enumerate
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8027 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8028 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8029 @end deffn
8030
8031 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8032 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8036 @cindex Cortex-M
8037
8038 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8039 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8040
8041 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8042 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8043 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8044 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8045 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8046 the step command leaves with the core running.
8047
8048 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8049 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8050 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8051
8052 Default is @option{auto}.
8053 @end deffn
8054
8055 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8056 @cindex vector_catch
8057 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8058 for certain hardware events.
8059
8060 Parameters request interception of
8061 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8062 @option{none} of them,
8063 or one or more of the following:
8064 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8065 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8066 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8067 @option{irq_err},
8068 @option{state_err},
8069 @option{chk_err}, or
8070 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8071 @option{reset}.
8072 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8073 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8074 are mapped to HardFault.
8075 UsageFault checks for
8076 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8077 must also be explicitly enabled.
8078
8079 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8080 @end deffn
8081
8082 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8083 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8084 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8085 @itemize @minus
8086 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8087 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8088 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8089 @end itemize
8090 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8091 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8092 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8093 the peripherals.
8094 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8095 @end deffn
8096
8097 @section Intel Architecture
8098
8099 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8100 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8101 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8102 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8103 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8104 @itemize
8105 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8106 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8107 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8108 @end itemize
8109
8110 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8111 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8112 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8113
8114 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8115 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8119 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8120 @end deffn
8121
8122 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8123 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8124 @end deffn
8125
8126 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8127 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8131 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8135 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8136 @end deffn
8137
8138 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8139
8140 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8141 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8142
8143 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8144 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8145 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8146 @end deffn
8147 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8148 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8149
8150 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8151
8152 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8153 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8154 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8155 @end deffn
8156
8157 @subsection Registers commands
8158 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8159 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8160 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8161
8162 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8163
8164 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8165 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8166 and "timer" groups.
8167
8168 @emph{example:}
8169 @example
8170 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8171 @end example
8172
8173
8174 @end deffn
8175 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8176 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8177
8178 @emph{group} can be "system",
8179 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8180 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8184 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8185 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8186 @cindex tracing
8187 @cindex libdcc
8188 @cindex DCC
8189 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8190 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8191 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8192 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8193
8194 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8195 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8196 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8197 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8198 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8199 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8200
8201 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8202 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8203 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8204 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8205 The target being debugged may
8206 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8207 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8208 each supported by a command:
8209
8210 @itemize
8211 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8212 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8213 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8214 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8215
8216 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8217 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8218 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8219
8220 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8221 and then displayed at any time.
8222 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8223
8224 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8225 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8226 @end itemize
8227
8228 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8229 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8230 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8231 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8232 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8233 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8234 does the same thing.
8235
8236 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8237 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8238 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8239 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8240 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8241
8242 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8243 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8244 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8248 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8249 in the order they triggered.
8250 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8251 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8252 history records.
8253 @end deffn
8254
8255 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8256 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8257 they have been triggered.
8258 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8259 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8260 and associates it with that identifier.
8261
8262 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8263 are not related except by this command.
8264 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8265 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268
8269 @node JTAG Commands
8270 @chapter JTAG Commands
8271 @cindex JTAG Commands
8272 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8273 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8274 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8275 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8276 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8277
8278 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8279 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8280
8281 @itemize @bullet
8282 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8283 devices such as a CPUs.
8284 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8285 standard state machine (in parallel)
8286 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8287 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8288 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8289 while the reading previous ones.
8290 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8291 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8292 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8293 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8294 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8295 registers.
8296 @end itemize
8297
8298 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8299
8300 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8301 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8302 the order of TAP state transitions.
8303 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8304 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8305 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8306 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8307 these commands are not available.
8308
8309 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8310 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8311 that specify the entire register.
8312 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8313 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8314 The return value holds the original value of each
8315 of those fields.
8316
8317 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8318 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8319 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8320 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8321 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8322
8323 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8324 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8325
8326 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8327 in that state.
8328 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8329 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8330 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8331
8332 @quotation Warning
8333 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8334 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8335 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8336 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8337 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8338 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8339 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8340 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8341 @end quotation
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8345 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8346 This may be used for performance tuning.
8347
8348 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8349 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8350 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8351 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8352 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8353 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8354 @end deffn
8355
8356 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8357 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8358 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8359 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8360 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8361 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8362
8363 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8364 in that state.
8365 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8366 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8367 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8368
8369 @quotation Note
8370 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8371 register values, unlike data register values.
8372 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8373 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8374 @end quotation
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8378 Set values of reset signals.
8379 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8380 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8381 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8382 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8383 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8384 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8385 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8386
8387 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8388 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8389 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8390 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8391 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8392 instead of the TRST signal.
8393 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8394 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8395 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8396 with handlers for that event.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8400 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8401 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8402 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8403 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8404 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8405 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8406 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8407 The final state must also be stable.
8408 @end deffn
8409
8410 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8411 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8412 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8413 Instructions often need some time
8414 to execute before they take effect.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8418 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8419
8420 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8421 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8422 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8423 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8424 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8425 @end deffn
8426
8427 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8428 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8429 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8430 must also be enabled.
8431 Default is enabled.
8432 @end deffn
8433
8434 @section TAP state names
8435 @cindex TAP state names
8436
8437 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8438 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8439 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8440 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8441
8442 @itemize @bullet
8443 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8444 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8445 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8446 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8447 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8448 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8449 through the data register
8450 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8451 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8452 for update or more shifting
8453 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8454 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8455 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8456 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8457 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8458 through the instruction register
8459 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8460 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8461 for update or more shifting
8462 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8463 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8464 @end itemize
8465
8466 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8467 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8468 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8469 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8470
8471 @itemize @bullet
8472 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8473 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8474 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8475 may not be as expected.
8476 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8477 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8478 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8479 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8480 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8481 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8482 @end itemize
8483
8484 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8485 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8486
8487 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8488 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8489 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8490 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8491
8492 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8493 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8494 @cindex SVF
8495
8496 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8497 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8498 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8499 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8500
8501 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8502 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8503 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8504 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8505 each command is logged before it is executed.
8506 @end deffn
8507
8508 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8509 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8510 @cindex XSVF
8511
8512 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8513 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8514 Xilinx devices.
8515 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8516 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8517
8518 @quotation Important
8519 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8520 @end quotation
8521
8522 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8523 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8524 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8525 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8526 that TAP.
8527 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8528 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8529 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8530 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8534 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8535 after building the software.
8536 You may find them useful:
8537
8538 @itemize
8539 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8540 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8541 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8542 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8543 @end itemize
8544
8545 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8546 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8547 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8548 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8549 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8550 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8551 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8552
8553
8554 @node Utility Commands
8555 @chapter Utility Commands
8556 @cindex Utility Commands
8557
8558 @section RAM testing
8559 @cindex RAM testing
8560
8561 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8562 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8563 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8564 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8565 hardware problems.
8566
8567 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8568 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8569 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8570 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8571
8572 Load the memory testing functions with
8573
8574 @example
8575 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8576 @end example
8577
8578 to get access to the following facilities:
8579
8580 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8581 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8582 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8586 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8587 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8588 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8589 @end deffn
8590
8591 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8592 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8593 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8594 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8595 @end deffn
8596
8597 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8598 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8602 @cindex Firmware recovery
8603
8604 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8605 devices recovery with JTAG.
8606
8607 For quickstart instructions run:
8608 @example
8609 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8610 @end example
8611
8612 @node TFTP
8613 @chapter TFTP
8614 @cindex TFTP
8615 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8616 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8617
8618 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8619 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8620 server (tftpd). For example,
8621
8622 @example
8623 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8624 @end example
8625
8626 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8627 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8628
8629 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8630 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8631 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8632 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8633
8634 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8635 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8636 @cindex GDB
8637 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8638 to debug remote targets.
8639 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8640
8641 @itemize
8642 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8643 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8644 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8645 as shown in this chapter.
8646 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8647 that also will probably need to be configured.
8648 @end itemize
8649
8650 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8651 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8652 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8653 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8654 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8655 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8656
8657 @section Connecting to GDB
8658 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8659 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8660 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8661 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8662 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8663
8664 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8665
8666 @enumerate
8667 @item
8668 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8669 @example
8670 target remote localhost:3333
8671 @end example
8672 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8673
8674 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8675 @example
8676 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8677 @end example
8678 @item
8679 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8680 @example
8681 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8682 @end example
8683 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8684 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8685 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8686 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8687 @end enumerate
8688
8689 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8690 GDB command line.
8691
8692 @section Sample GDB session startup
8693
8694 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8695 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8696 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8697 small ARM program.
8698 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8699 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8700
8701 @example
8702 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8703 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8704 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8705 ...
8706 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8707 ...
8708 (gdb) load
8709 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8710 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8711 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8712 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8713 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8714 (gdb) continue
8715 Continuing.
8716 ...
8717 @end example
8718
8719 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8720 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8721 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8722 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8723
8724 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8725
8726 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8727 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8728 packet size and the device's memory map.
8729 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8730 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8731 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8732
8733 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8734 You may need to set those up by hand.
8735 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8736 something like:
8737
8738 @example
8739 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8740 @end example
8741
8742 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8743
8744 @example
8745 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8746 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8747 @end example
8748
8749 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8750 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8751 do not have such restrictions.
8752
8753 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8754 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8755 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8756
8757 @example
8758 define hook-step
8759 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8760 end
8761 define hookpost-step
8762 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8763 end
8764 @end example
8765
8766 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8767 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8768 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8769 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8770
8771 @section Programming using GDB
8772 @cindex Programming using GDB
8773 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8774
8775 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8776 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8777 @example
8778 gdb_memory_map disable
8779 @end example
8780 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8781 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8782 working area.
8783
8784 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8785 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8786 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8787 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8788
8789 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8790 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8791
8792 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8793 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8794 @example
8795 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8796 @end example
8797
8798 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8799 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8800
8801 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8802 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8803 will be used.
8804
8805 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8806 script can be executed:
8807 @example
8808 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8809 @end example
8810
8811 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8812 can be used.
8813 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8814 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8815 @cindex SMP
8816 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8817 @itemize @bullet
8818 @item j - smp status request
8819 @item J - smp set request
8820 @end itemize
8821
8822 OpenOCD implements :
8823 @itemize @bullet
8824 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8825 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8826 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8827 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8828 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8829 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8830 @end itemize
8831
8832 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8833 @itemize @bullet
8834 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8835 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8836 @example
8837 set $_core 1
8838 #Jc01 packet is sent
8839 print $_core
8840 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8841 @end example
8842
8843 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8844 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8845
8846 @example
8847 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8848 define toggle0
8849 maint packet Jc0
8850 continue
8851 main packet Jc-1
8852 end
8853 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8854 define toggle1
8855 maint packet Jc1
8856 continue
8857 main packet Jc-1
8858 end
8859 @end example
8860 @end itemize
8861
8862 @section RTOS Support
8863 @cindex RTOS Support
8864 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8865
8866 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8867 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8868
8869 @* An example setup is below:
8870
8871 @example
8872 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8873 @end example
8874
8875 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8876
8877 Currently supported rtos's include:
8878 @itemize @bullet
8879 @item @option{eCos}
8880 @item @option{ThreadX}
8881 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8882 @item @option{linux}
8883 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8884 @item @option{embKernel}
8885 @item @option{mqx}
8886 @end itemize
8887
8888 @quotation Note
8889 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8890 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8891 @end quotation
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item eCos symbols
8895 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8896 @item ThreadX symbols
8897 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8898 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8899 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8900 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8901 @tex
8902 \begingroup
8903 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8904 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8905 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8906 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8907 \par
8908 \endgroup
8909 @end tex
8910 @item linux symbols
8911 init_task.
8912 @item ChibiOS symbols
8913 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8914 @item embKernel symbols
8915 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8916 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8917 @item mqx symbols
8918 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8919 @end table
8920
8921 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8922 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8923
8924 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8925 along with the project:
8926
8927 @table @code
8928 @item FreeRTOS
8929 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8930 @end table
8931
8932 @node Tcl Scripting API
8933 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8934 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8935 @cindex Tcl scripts
8936 @section API rules
8937
8938 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8939 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8940 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8941
8942 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8943 pair list and lists.
8944
8945 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8946 list.
8947
8948 @example
8949 > set foo(me) Duane
8950 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8951 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8952 > set foo(duck) Donald
8953 @end example
8954
8955 If one does this:
8956
8957 @example
8958 > set foo
8959 @end example
8960
8961 The result is:
8962
8963 @example
8964 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8965 @end example
8966
8967 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8968
8969 @verbatim
8970 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8971 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8972 }
8973 @end verbatim
8974
8975 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8976 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8977
8978 @section Internal low-level Commands
8979
8980 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8981 invoke directly.
8982
8983 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8984 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8985 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8986
8987 @itemize @bullet
8988 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8989
8990 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8991 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8992
8993 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8994 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8995
8996 Return information about the flash banks
8997
8998 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8999
9000 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9001 its execution. Example:
9002
9003 @example
9004 > capture "reset init"
9005 @end example
9006
9007 @end itemize
9008
9009 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9010 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9011 called "flash_banks".
9012
9013 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9014
9015 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9016 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9017 holds one of the following values:
9018
9019 @itemize @bullet
9020 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9021 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9022 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9023 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9024 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9025 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9026 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9027 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9028 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9029 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9030 @end itemize
9031
9032 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9033
9034 @quotation Note
9035 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9036 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9037 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9038 is jim, not real tcl).
9039 @end quotation
9040
9041 @section Tcl RPC server
9042 @cindex RPC
9043
9044 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9045 commands and receive the results.
9046
9047 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9048 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9049 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9050 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9051 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9052
9053 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9054 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9055 @command{capture} command.
9056
9057 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9058
9059 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9060 @cindex RPC Notifications
9061
9062 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9063 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9064
9065 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9066 in the following format.
9067
9068 @verbatim
9069 type target_event event [event-name]
9070 type target_state state [state-name]
9071 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9072 @end verbatim
9073
9074 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9075 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9076 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9077 Defaults to off.
9078
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9082 @cindex RPC trace output
9083
9084 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9085 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9086
9087 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9088
9089 @verbatim
9090 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9091 @end verbatim
9092
9093 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9094 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9095 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9096 Defaults to off.
9097
9098 See an example application here:
9099 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9100
9101 @end deffn
9102
9103 @node FAQ
9104 @chapter FAQ
9105 @cindex faq
9106 @enumerate
9107 @anchor{faqrtck}
9108 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9109 @cindex RTCK
9110 @cindex adaptive clocking
9111 @*
9112
9113 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9114 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9115 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9116 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9117
9118 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9119 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9120 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9121 @enumerate
9122 @item
9123 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9124 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9125 @item
9126 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9127 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9128 @end enumerate
9129
9130 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9131 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9132 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9133 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9134 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9135 power).
9136
9137 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9138 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9139 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9140 ARM926 scenario).
9141 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9142 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9143 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9144
9145 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9146 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9147 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9148 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9149
9150 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9151
9152 In order to make use of this,
9153 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9154 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9155
9156 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9157 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9158 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9159 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9160 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9161
9162 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9163 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9164 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9165 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9166
9167 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9168 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9169 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9170 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9171 with a CPLD.
9172 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9173 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9174 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9175 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9176 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9177 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9178
9179 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9180
9181 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9182
9183 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9184 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9185 depending on the chips on your board.
9186 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9187 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9188 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9189
9190 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9191 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9192 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9193
9194 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9195 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9196 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9197 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9198
9199 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9200 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9201 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9202 this way.
9203
9204 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9205 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9206 clock rate.
9207 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9208 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9209 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9210
9211 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9212
9213 @example
9214 # Example: 1.234MHz
9215 adapter_khz 1234
9216 @end example
9217
9218
9219 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9220
9221 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9222 around Windows filenames.
9223
9224 @example
9225 > echo \a
9226
9227 > echo @{\a@}
9228 \a
9229 > echo "\a"
9230
9231 >
9232 @end example
9233
9234
9235 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9236
9237 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9238 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9239 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9240
9241 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9242 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9243 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9244
9245 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9246 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9247 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9248
9249 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9250
9251 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9252 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9253 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9254 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9255
9256 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9257 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9258 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9259
9260 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9261 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9262
9263 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9264 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9265 memory read caused data abort".
9266
9267 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9268 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9269 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9270 be done, feel free to add this here.
9271
9272 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9273 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9274 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9275 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9276 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9277 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9278 gracefully stops.
9279
9280 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9281 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9282 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9283
9284 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9285 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9286 bytes. Painful...
9287
9288
9289 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9290 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9291
9292 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9293 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9294 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9295 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9296 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9297 reset, everything else should work fine.
9298
9299 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9300 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9301 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9302 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9303
9304 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9305 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9306 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9307 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9308
9309 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9310
9311 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9312 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9313 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9314 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9315
9316 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9317 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9318 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9319 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9320
9321 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9322 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9323 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9324
9325 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9326 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9327
9328 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9329 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9330 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9331 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9332 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9333 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9334 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9335 clock frequency?
9336
9337 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9338 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9339 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9340 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9341 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9342
9343 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9344
9345 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9346 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9347 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9348 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9349 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9350 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9351 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9352
9353 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9354
9355 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9356 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9357 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9358 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9359
9360 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9361 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9362 particular order?
9363
9364 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9365 the same order used by the hardware.
9366
9367 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9368 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9369 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9370 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9371 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9372 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9373
9374 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9375 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9376 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9377 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9378
9379 @itemize @bullet
9380 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9381 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9382 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9383 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9384 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9385 @end itemize
9386
9387 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9388
9389 @itemize @bullet
9390 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9391 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9392 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9393 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9394 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9395 @end itemize
9396
9397
9398 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9399 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9400 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9401
9402 TODO.
9403
9404 @end enumerate
9405
9406 @node Tcl Crash Course
9407 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9408 @cindex Tcl
9409
9410 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9411 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9412 how the Tcl scripts work.
9413
9414 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9415 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9416 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9417 OpenOCD.
9418
9419 @section Tcl Rule #1
9420 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9421 @enumerate
9422 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9423 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9424 @end enumerate
9425
9426 The Tcl equal is this:
9427
9428 @enumerate
9429 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9430 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9431 @end enumerate
9432
9433 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9434 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9435
9436 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9437 There is a second pair of rules.
9438 @enumerate
9439 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9440 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9441 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9442 in Tcl.
9443 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9444 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9445 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9446 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9447 @end enumerate
9448
9449 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9450 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9451 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9452 Everything is a string}
9453
9454 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9455 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9456 difference is subtle.
9457 @enumerate
9458 @item Parse Time
9459 @item Evaluation Time
9460 @end enumerate
9461
9462 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9463 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9464 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9465
9466 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9467 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9468 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9469 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9470
9471 @itemize @bullet
9472 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9473 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9474 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9475 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9476 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9477 @example
9478 # bash example
9479 X=`date`
9480 echo "The Date is: $X"
9481 # Tcl example
9482 set X [date]
9483 puts "The Date is: $X"
9484 @end example
9485 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9486 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9487 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9488 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9489 is a string}
9490 @example
9491 set x "Dinner"
9492 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9493 @end example
9494 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9495 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9496 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9497 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9498 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9499 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9500 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9501 @end itemize
9502
9503 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9504
9505 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9506
9507 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9508
9509 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9510 the normal way.
9511
9512 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9513 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9514 line is immedatly executed.
9515
9516 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9517 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9518
9519 @subsection Command Execution
9520
9521 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9522 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9523 control flow operators.
9524
9525 Commands are executed like this:
9526
9527 @enumerate
9528 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9529 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9530 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9531 @end enumerate
9532
9533 It sort of works like this:
9534 @example
9535 for(;;)@{
9536 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9537
9538 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9539
9540 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9541 @}
9542 @end example
9543
9544 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9545 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9546 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9547 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9548 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9549 ``LookupCommand()''
9550
9551 @subsection The FOR command
9552
9553 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9554 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9555 command just like any other command.
9556
9557 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9558 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9559 are:
9560
9561 @enumerate 0
9562 @item The ascii text 'for'
9563 @item The start text
9564 @item The test expression
9565 @item The next text
9566 @item The body text
9567 @end enumerate
9568
9569 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9570 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9571 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9572 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9573
9574 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9575 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9576
9577 @example
9578 int
9579 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9580 int *argc,
9581 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9582 @end example
9583
9584 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9585 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9586 still operates in the same basic way.
9587
9588 @subsection FOR command implementation
9589
9590 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9591 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9592
9593 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9594
9595 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9596
9597 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9598 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9599 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9600
9601 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9602 expression and returns a value.
9603
9604 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9605 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9606 @example
9607 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9608
9609 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9610
9611 int
9612 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9613 int argc,
9614 char **argv )
9615 @{
9616 if( argc != 5 )@{
9617 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9618 return ERROR;
9619 @}
9620
9621 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9622
9623 // Execute the start statement.
9624 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9625
9626 // Top of loop test
9627 for(;;)@{
9628 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9629 if( i == 0 )
9630 break;
9631
9632 // Execute the body
9633 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9634
9635 // Execute the LOOP part
9636 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9637 @}
9638
9639 // Return no error
9640 SetResult( interp, "" );
9641 return SUCCESS;
9642 @}
9643 @end example
9644
9645 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9646 in the same basic way.
9647
9648 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9649
9650 @subsection source and find commands
9651 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9652 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9653 @*Remember the parsing rules
9654 @enumerate
9655 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9656 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9657 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9658 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9659 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9660 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9661 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9662 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9663 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9664 @end enumerate
9665 @subsection format command
9666 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9667 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9668 @b{sprintf()}.
9669 @b{Example}
9670 @example
9671 set x 6
9672 set y 7
9673 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9674 @end example
9675 @enumerate
9676 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9677 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9678 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9679 @* Refer to Rule #1
9680 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9681 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9682 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9683 @end enumerate
9684 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9685 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9686 @example
9687 #1 Good
9688 proc someproc @{@} @{
9689 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9690 @}
9691 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9692 #2 Good - no variables
9693 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9694 #3 Good Curly Braces
9695 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9696 puts "Time: [date]"
9697 @}
9698 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9699 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9700 @end example
9701 @enumerate
9702 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9703 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9704 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9705 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9706 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9707 command.
9708 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9709 @*There are 4 examples:
9710 @enumerate
9711 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9712 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9713 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9714 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9715 @end enumerate
9716
9717 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9718 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9719 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9720
9721 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9722 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9723 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9724 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9725 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9726 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9727 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9728 @end enumerate
9729 @subsection Global Variables
9730 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9731 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9732 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9733 @example
9734 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9735 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9736 global x #Global variable X
9737 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9738 @}
9739 @end example
9740 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9741 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9742 @example
9743 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9744 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9745 # Create var name
9746 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9747 # Make it a global
9748 global $vn
9749 # Set it.
9750 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9751 @}
9752 @end example
9753 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9754 @example
9755 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9756 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9757 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9758 @}
9759 @end example
9760
9761 @include fdl.texi
9762
9763 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9764 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9765 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9766 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9767 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9768 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9769
9770 @printindex cp
9771
9772 @node Command and Driver Index
9773 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9774 @printindex fn
9775
9776 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)